diff --git a/bicep/main.bicep b/bicep/main.bicep index 3b3de060..a5d0af57 100644 --- a/bicep/main.bicep +++ b/bicep/main.bicep @@ -1,8 +1,10 @@ targetScope = 'resourceGroup' +// BUG RIGHT NOW. https://github.com/Azure/azure-dev/pull/5061 @description('Specify the Azure region to place the application definition.') -param location string = resourceGroup().location +// param location string = resourceGroup().location +param location string @description('Specify the User Email.') param emailAddress string @@ -137,14 +139,16 @@ var configuration = { 'azure-webjobs-hosts' 'azure-webjobs-eventhub' 'gitops' + 'airflow-logs' + 'airflow-dags' + 'share-unit' + 'share-crs' + 'share-crs-conversion' ] tables: [ 'partitionInfo' ] - shares: [ - 'airflow-logs' - 'airflow-dags' - ] + shares: [] } partitions: [ { @@ -776,11 +780,12 @@ module storage 'modules/storage-account/main.bicep' = { ] // Apply Security - allowBlobPublicAccess: false + // allowBlobPublicAccess: false` publicNetworkAccess: 'Enabled' + enableHierarchicalNamespace: false // <--- Airflow doesn't like hiearchical. // TODO: This is required for Partition Service to access the storage account. Issue: https://github.com/Azure/osdu-developer/issues/230 - allowSharedKeyAccess: true + allowSharedKeyAccess: false // https://learn.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/azure-resource-manager/templates/deployment-script-template?tabs=CLI#debug-deployment-scripts networkAcls: { @@ -1062,6 +1067,7 @@ module configBlade 'modules/blade_configuration.bicep' = { managedIdentityName: stampIdentity.outputs.name kvName: keyvault.outputs.name kvUri: keyvault.outputs.uri + storageAccountName: storage.outputs.name appInsightsKey: insights.outputs.instrumentationKey partitionStorageNames: partitionBlade.outputs.partitionStorageNames partitionServiceBusNames: partitionBlade.outputs.partitionServiceBusNames diff --git a/bicep/main.parameters.json b/bicep/main.parameters.json index 909f8c70..e1cfbced 100644 --- a/bicep/main.parameters.json +++ b/bicep/main.parameters.json @@ -5,9 +5,6 @@ "applicationClientId": { "value": "${AZURE_CLIENT_ID}" }, - "applicationClientSecret": { - "value": "${AZURE_CLIENT_SECRET}" - }, "applicationClientPrincipalOid": { "value": "${AZURE_CLIENT_PRINCIPAL_OID}" }, diff --git a/bicep/modules/blade_cluster.bicep b/bicep/modules/blade_cluster.bicep index b66da5b9..87269739 100644 --- a/bicep/modules/blade_cluster.bicep +++ b/bicep/modules/blade_cluster.bicep @@ -190,7 +190,7 @@ module cluster './managed-cluster/main.bicep' = { enableStorageProfileDiskCSIDriver: true enableStorageProfileFileCSIDriver: true enableStorageProfileSnapshotController: true - enableStorageProfileBlobCSIDriver: true + enableStorageProfileBlobCSIDriver: false enableKeyvaultSecretsProvider: true enableSecretRotation: true enableImageCleaner: true diff --git a/bicep/modules/blade_configuration.bicep b/bicep/modules/blade_configuration.bicep index a13a5a09..546f2014 100644 --- a/bicep/modules/blade_configuration.bicep +++ b/bicep/modules/blade_configuration.bicep @@ -81,6 +81,9 @@ param osduVersion string = 'master' @description('The managed identity name for deployment scripts') param managedIdentityName string +@description('The name of the system storage account') +param storageAccountName string + @description('The name of the partition storage accounts') param partitionStorageNames string[] @@ -392,7 +395,7 @@ var configMaps = { values.yaml: | serviceAccount: create: false - name: "workload-identity-sa" + name: workload-identity-sa azure: tenantId: {0} clientId: {1} @@ -403,12 +406,15 @@ values.yaml: | appId: {6} appOid: {7} resourceGroup: {8} + storageAccountName: {11} ingress: internalGateway: enabled: {9} externalGateway: enabled: {10} - ''' + workloadIdentity: + clientID: {1} +''' } /* @@ -445,7 +451,8 @@ module appConfigMap './aks-config-map/main.bicep' = { applicationClientPrincipalOid, resourceGroup().name, clusterIngress == 'Internal' || clusterIngress == 'Both' ? 'true' : 'false', - clusterIngress == 'External' || clusterIngress == 'Both' ? 'true' : 'false') + clusterIngress == 'External' || clusterIngress == 'Both' ? 'true' : 'false', + storageAccountName) ] } } diff --git a/bicep/modules/blade_partition.bicep b/bicep/modules/blade_partition.bicep index e8ff7836..1b7ed5d1 100644 --- a/bicep/modules/blade_partition.bicep +++ b/bicep/modules/blade_partition.bicep @@ -518,7 +518,7 @@ module storage 'storage-account/main.bicep' = [for (partition, index) in partiti // Apply Security allowBlobPublicAccess: enableBlobPublicAccess publicNetworkAccess: 'Enabled' - allowSharedKeyAccess: true + allowSharedKeyAccess: false // https://learn.microsoft.com/en-us/azure/azure-resource-manager/templates/deployment-script-template?tabs=CLI#debug-deployment-scripts networkAcls: { bypass: 'AzureServices' @@ -602,9 +602,33 @@ module partitionDb './cosmos-db/main.bicep' = [for (partition, index) in partiti databaseEndpointSecretName: '${partition.name}-${partitionLayerConfig.secrets.cosmosEndpoint}' databasePrimaryKeySecretName: '${partition.name}-${partitionLayerConfig.secrets.cosmosPrimaryKey}' databaseConnectionStringSecretName: '${partition.name}-${partitionLayerConfig.secrets.cosmosConnectionString}' + + roleAssignments: [ + { + roleDefinitionIdOrName: 'Contributor' + principals: [ + { + id: stampIdentity.properties.principalId + } + ] + principalType: 'ServicePrincipal' + } + ] } }] +// Add SQL role assignment for the Cosmos DB account +module sqlRoleAssignment './cosmosdb-sql-role-assignment.bicep' = [for (partition, index) in partitions: { + name: '${bladeConfig.sectionName}-cosmos-db-sql-role-${index}' + params: { + databaseAccountName: partitionDb[index].outputs.name + principalId: stampIdentity.properties.principalId + roleDefinitionId: '${partitionDb[index].outputs.id}/sqlRoleDefinitions/00000000-0000-0000-0000-000000000002' // Built-in Cosmos DB Built-in Data Contributor + } + dependsOn: [ + partitionDb[index] + ] +}] // First, create a variable to handle the subscription mapping var topicsWithSubscriptions = [for topic in partitionLayerConfig.servicebus.topics: { diff --git a/bicep/modules/cosmos-db/main.bicep b/bicep/modules/cosmos-db/main.bicep index f4de069e..1adffaff 100644 --- a/bicep/modules/cosmos-db/main.bicep +++ b/bicep/modules/cosmos-db/main.bicep @@ -340,7 +340,7 @@ var databaseAccount_properties = union({ // Create Database Account -resource databaseAccount 'Microsoft.DocumentDB/databaseAccounts@2022-08-15' = { +resource databaseAccount 'Microsoft.DocumentDB/databaseAccounts@2024-11-15' = { name: length(name) > 26 ? substring(name, 0, 26) : name location: resourceLocation tags: tags diff --git a/bicep/modules/cosmosdb-sql-role-assignment.bicep b/bicep/modules/cosmosdb-sql-role-assignment.bicep new file mode 100644 index 00000000..24895c30 --- /dev/null +++ b/bicep/modules/cosmosdb-sql-role-assignment.bicep @@ -0,0 +1,35 @@ +@description('Name of the Cosmos DB account') +param databaseAccountName string + +@description('Name of the SQL database (if scope is at database level)') +@allowed([ '', 'database' ]) +param databaseName string = '' + +@description('Optional custom scope. If provided, overrides databaseName logic.') +param customScope string = '' + +@description('Principal (Object ID) of the identity to assign') +param principalId string + +@description('Full resource ID of the Cosmos DB SQL role definition') +param roleDefinitionId string + +resource cosmosDbAccount 'Microsoft.DocumentDB/databaseAccounts@2024-11-15' existing = { + name: databaseAccountName +} + +var resolvedScope = !empty(customScope) + ? customScope + : !empty(databaseName) + ? '${cosmosDbAccount.id}/sqlDatabases/${databaseName}' + : cosmosDbAccount.id + +resource sqlRoleAssignment 'Microsoft.DocumentDB/databaseAccounts/sqlRoleAssignments@2024-11-15' = { + name: guid(cosmosDbAccount.id, principalId, roleDefinitionId) + parent: cosmosDbAccount + properties: { + roleDefinitionId: roleDefinitionId + principalId: principalId + scope: resolvedScope + } +} diff --git a/charts/osdu-developer-base/templates/storage-share-job.yaml b/charts/osdu-developer-base/templates/storage-share-job.yaml index 38bea328..a24996ca 100644 --- a/charts/osdu-developer-base/templates/storage-share-job.yaml +++ b/charts/osdu-developer-base/templates/storage-share-job.yaml @@ -1,17 +1,4 @@ {{- if .Values.share.enabled -}} -apiVersion: v1 -kind: PersistentVolumeClaim -metadata: - name: {{ .Release.Name }}-pvc - namespace: {{ .Release.Namespace }} -spec: - storageClassName: osdu-managed-disk - accessModes: - - ReadWriteMany - resources: - requests: - storage: 1Gi ---- {{- range $index, $item := .Values.share.items }} apiVersion: batch/v1 kind: Job @@ -28,9 +15,9 @@ spec: configMap: name: storage-share-script defaultMode: 0500 - - name: {{ $.Release.Name }}-storage + - name: storage persistentVolumeClaim: - claimName: {{ $.Release.Name }}-pvc + claimName: {{ $item.pvc }} initContainers: - name: data-seed image: mcr.microsoft.com/cbl-mariner/base/core:2.0 @@ -43,7 +30,7 @@ spec: volumeMounts: - name: script mountPath: "/script" - - name: {{ $.Release.Name }}-storage + - name: storage mountPath: "/share" env: - name: URL @@ -96,19 +83,16 @@ data: exit 1 fi - # Create the target directory in /share mounted volume - mkdir -p /share/${SHARE} - # Check if the URL indicates a tar.gz file if [[ ${URL} == *.tar.gz ]]; then echo "URL indicates a tar.gz archive. Extracting contents..." - + # Create a directory for extracted files mkdir -p extracted_files - + # Extract the tar.gz file tar -xzf ${url_basename} --strip-components=1 -C extracted_files - + if [[ ${compress} == "True" ]]; then echo "Creating zip of contents of ${FILE} and copying it to /share" # Remove the original downloaded tar file @@ -124,23 +108,33 @@ data: # Create the zip from the contents without including the extracted_files/${FILE} path itself zip -r ${original_dir}/${zip_filename} * - + # Navigate back to the original directory cd ${original_dir} - + # Copy the zip file to the /share mounted volume - cp ${zip_filename} /share/${SHARE} + cp ${zip_filename} /share/ echo "Zip file ${zip_filename} copied to /share." else - # Batch copy the extracted files to the /share mounted volume echo "Copying extracted files to /share with pattern ${FILE}/**" - cp -r extracted_files/${FILE} /share/${SHARE} + + SOURCE_DIR="extracted_files/${FILE}" + TARGET_DIR="/share/${FILE}" + + cd "$SOURCE_DIR" + + find . -type f | while read -r file; do + relative_path="${file#./}" + dest_path="${TARGET_DIR}/${relative_path}" + install -D "$file" "$dest_path" + echo "Copied: $file -> $dest_path" + done fi echo "Files from ${url_basename} copied to /share." else # Copy the file to the /share mounted volume echo "Copying file ${FILE} to /share" - cp ${FILE} /share/${SHARE} + cp ${FILE} /share/ echo "File ${FILE} copied to /share." fi {{- end }} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/charts/osdu-developer-base/values.yaml b/charts/osdu-developer-base/values.yaml index 82db7a6b..4dccfa6a 100644 --- a/charts/osdu-developer-base/values.yaml +++ b/charts/osdu-developer-base/values.yaml @@ -1,4 +1,3 @@ - fullnameOverride: osdu-svc ################################################################################ @@ -27,9 +26,11 @@ share: enabled: false items: - name: folder + pvc: "" file: "file" url: "https://example.com/folder/file.json" - name: item2 + pvc: "" url: "https://example.com/archive.tar.gz" file: "folder_in_archive" compress: true diff --git a/charts/storage-volumes/Chart.yaml b/charts/storage-volumes/Chart.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..60e462c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/charts/storage-volumes/Chart.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ +apiVersion: v2 +name: storage-volumes +description: A Chart for creating kubernetes persistent volumes and claims + +# A chart can be either an 'application' or a 'library' chart. +# +# Application charts are a collection of templates that can be packaged into versioned archives +# to be deployed. +# +# Library charts provide useful utilities or functions for the chart developer. They're included as +# a dependency of application charts to inject those utilities and functions into the rendering +# pipeline. Library charts do not define any templates and therefore cannot be deployed. +type: application + +# This is the chart version. This version number should be incremented each time you make changes +# to the chart and its templates, including the app version. +# Versions are expected to follow Semantic Versioning (https://semver.org/) +version: 0.0.1 + +# This is the version number of the application being deployed. This version number should be +# incremented each time you make changes to the application. Versions are not expected to +# follow Semantic Versioning. They should reflect the version the application is using. +appVersion: 0.0.1 + +maintainers: + - name: danielscholl + url: https://github.com/danielscholl \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/charts/storage-volumes/README.md b/charts/storage-volumes/README.md new file mode 100644 index 00000000..ea50fc52 --- /dev/null +++ b/charts/storage-volumes/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,44 @@ +# storage-volumes Helm Chart + +This Helm chart provisions Azure Blob-backed PersistentVolumes (PV) and PersistentVolumeClaims (PVC) in Kubernetes using the Azure Blob CSI driver. + +## Values + +| Key | Description | Required | Default | +|--------------------|--------------------------------------------------|----------|-------------------| +| azure.clientId | Azure AD workload identity client ID | Yes | - | +| azure.resourceGroup| Azure resource group name | Yes | - | +| azure.storageAccountName | Azure storage account name | Yes | - | +| volumes | List of volume definitions (see below) | Yes | - | +| volumes[].volumeName | Name for the PV and PVC | Yes | - | +| volumes[].containerName | Azure blob container name for this volume | Yes | - | +| volumes[].storageSize| Storage size for PV/PVC | No | 5Gi | +| volumes[].accessModes | List of access modes (e.g. ReadWriteMany) | No | [ReadWriteMany] | + + +### Example `values.yaml` + +```yaml +azure: + clientId: "" + resourceGroup: "" + storageAccountName: "" + +volumes: + - volumeName: "blob-persistent-pv" + containerName: "" + # Optional, defaults shown + storageSize: "10Gi" + accessModes: + - ReadWriteMany +``` + +## Usage + +Install or upgrade the chart with your custom values: + +```bash +helm upgrade --install storage-volumes ./storage-volumes -n -f values.yaml +``` + +This will create a PersistentVolume and PersistentVolumeClaim for each entry in `volumes`, using the Azure Blob CSI driver. diff --git a/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pv.yaml b/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pv.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..d54d035d --- /dev/null +++ b/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pv.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,33 @@ +{{- range .Values.volumes }} +apiVersion: v1 +kind: PersistentVolume +metadata: + name: {{ .volumeName }} + annotations: + pv.kubernetes.io/provisioned-by: blob.csi.azure.com +spec: + capacity: + storage: {{ default "5Gi" .storageSize }} + accessModes: + {{- range default (list "ReadWriteMany") .accessModes }} + - {{ . }} + {{- end }} + persistentVolumeReclaimPolicy: Retain + storageClassName: azureblob-fuse-premium + mountOptions: + - "-o allow_other" + - "--file-cache-timeout-in-seconds=120" + - "--use-attr-cache=true" + - "--cancel-list-on-mount-seconds=0" + - "--log-level=LOG_DEBUG" + csi: + driver: blob.csi.azure.com + volumeHandle: {{ $.Values.azure.resourceGroup }}#{{ $.Values.azure.storageAccountName }}#{{ .containerName }} + volumeAttributes: + storageaccount: {{ $.Values.azure.storageAccountName }} + containerName: {{ .containerName }} + clientID: {{ $.Values.azure.clientId }} + resourcegroup: {{ $.Values.azure.resourceGroup }} + protocol: fuse +--- +{{- end }} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pvc.yaml b/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pvc.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..62a7134a --- /dev/null +++ b/charts/storage-volumes/templates/pvc.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,17 @@ +{{- range .Values.volumes }} +apiVersion: v1 +kind: PersistentVolumeClaim +metadata: + name: {{ .volumeName }}-pvc +spec: + accessModes: + {{- range default (list "ReadWriteMany") .accessModes }} + - {{ . }} + {{- end }} + resources: + requests: + storage: {{ default "5Gi" .storageSize }} + volumeName: {{ .volumeName }} + storageClassName: azureblob-fuse-premium +--- +{{- end }} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/charts/storage-volumes/values.yaml b/charts/storage-volumes/values.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..25868986 --- /dev/null +++ b/charts/storage-volumes/values.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,12 @@ +azure: + clientId: "" # Azure AD workload identity client ID + resourceGroup: "" # Azure resource group name + storageAccountName: "" # Azure storage account name + +volumes: + - volumeName: "" # Persistent volume name + containerName: "" # Azure blob container name for this volume + storageSize: "5Gi" # PVC storage request size + accessModes: + - ReadWriteMany + diff --git a/scripts/pre-provision.ps1 b/scripts/pre-provision.ps1 index 39d1aeca..02813fd2 100644 --- a/scripts/pre-provision.ps1 +++ b/scripts/pre-provision.ps1 @@ -11,8 +11,10 @@ Optionally specify an Azure environment name. Defaults to the value of the AZURE_ENV_NAME environment variable if set, or "dev" if not. .PARAMETER RequiredCliVersion Optionally specify the required Azure CLI version. Defaults to "2.60". +.PARAMETER ServiceManagementReference + Optionally specify a ServiceManagementReference. Defaults to an empty string if not provided. .EXAMPLE - .\pre-provision.ps1 -SubscriptionId -AzureEnvName -RequiredCliVersion "2.60" + .\pre-provision.ps1 -SubscriptionId -AzureEnvName -RequiredCliVersion "2.60" -ServiceManagementReference #> #Requires -Version 7.4 @@ -28,16 +30,19 @@ param ( [version]$RequiredCliVersion = [version]"2.60", + [string]$ServiceManagementReference = $env:AZURE_ASSET_NUMBER ? $env:AZURE_ASSET_NUMBER : [string]::Empty, + [switch]$Help ) function Show-Help { - Write-Host "Usage: .\hook-preprovision.ps1 [-SubscriptionId SUBSCRIPTION_ID] [-AzureEnvName AZURE_ENV_NAME] [-RequiredCliVersion REQUIRED_CLI_VERSION]" + Write-Host "Usage: .\hook-preprovision.ps1 [-SubscriptionId SUBSCRIPTION_ID] [-AzureEnvName AZURE_ENV_NAME] [-RequiredCliVersion REQUIRED_CLI_VERSION] [-ServiceManagementReference SERVICE_MANAGEMENT_REFERENCE]" Write-Host "Options:" Write-Host " -SubscriptionId : Optionally specify a subscription ID to use. If not provided, defaults to the AZURE_SUBSCRIPTION_ID environment variable." Write-Host " -ApplicationId : Optionally specify an application ID to use. If not provided, creates one." Write-Host " -AzureEnvName : Optionally specify an Azure environment name. Defaults to 'dev' if AZURE_ENV_NAME environment variable is not set." Write-Host " -RequiredCliVersion : Optionally specify the required Azure CLI version. Defaults to '2.60'." + Write-Host " -ServiceManagementReference : Optionally specify a ServiceManagementReference. Defaults to an empty string if not provided." Write-Host " -Help : Print this help message and exit" } @@ -155,6 +160,8 @@ function New-Application { { 'displayName': '$azureClientName', 'signInAudience': 'AzureADMyOrg', + 'serviceManagementReference': '$ServiceManagementReference', + 'notes': 'OSDU Data Platform', 'web': {'redirectUris': ['https://localhost:8080/'],'implicitGrantSettings': {'enableIdTokenIssuance': 'true', 'enableAccessTokenIssuance': 'true'}}, 'spa': {'redirectUris': ['https://localhost:8080/spa']}, 'requiredResourceAccess': [{'resourceAppId': '00000003-0000-0000-c000-000000000000', 'resourceAccess': [{'id': 'e1fe6dd8-ba31-4d61-89e7-88639da4683d', 'type': 'Scope'}]}] @@ -200,12 +207,6 @@ function Set-EnvironmentVariables { azd env set AZURE_CLIENT_PRINCIPAL_OID $azureClientPrincipalOid } - if (-not $env:AZURE_CLIENT_SECRET) { - Write-Host " Retrieving AZURE_CLIENT_SECRET..." - $azureClientSecret = az ad app credential reset --id $ApplicationId --query password --only-show-errors -o tsv - azd env set AZURE_CLIENT_SECRET $azureClientSecret - } - if (-not $env:EMAIL_ADDRESS) { Write-Host " Retrieving User Email Address..." $emailAddress = az ad signed-in-user show --query userPrincipalName -o tsv diff --git a/software/applications/osdu-reference/base.yaml b/software/applications/osdu-reference/base.yaml index df82e0b6..250ae4a3 100644 --- a/software/applications/osdu-reference/base.yaml +++ b/software/applications/osdu-reference/base.yaml @@ -35,11 +35,14 @@ spec: enabled: true items: - name: unit + pvc: "share-unit-pvc" file: "unit_catalog_v2.json" url: "https://community.opengroup.org/osdu/platform/system/reference/unit-service/-/raw/master/data/unit_catalog_v2.json" - name: crs + pvc: "share-crs-pvc" file: "crs_catalog_v2.json" url: "https://community.opengroup.org/osdu/platform/system/reference/crs-catalog-service/-/raw/master/data/crs_catalog_v2.json" - name: crs-conversion + pvc: "share-crs-conversion-pvc" file: "apachesis_setup" url: "https://community.opengroup.org/osdu/platform/system/reference/crs-conversion-service/-/archive/master/crs-conversion-service-master.tar.gz" \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-catalog.yaml b/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-catalog.yaml index 17c6f809..901a67ff 100644 --- a/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-catalog.yaml +++ b/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-catalog.yaml @@ -64,13 +64,12 @@ spec: - "/api/crs/catalog/api-docs*" - "/api/crs/catalog/webjars/*" pvc: - - name: osdu-reference-osdu-developer-base-reference + - name: share-crs existing: true volume: shared-data mount: - name: shared-data path: /mnt/crs_catalogs - subPath: crs env: - name: KEYVAULT_URI secret: diff --git a/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-conversion.yaml b/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-conversion.yaml index 3f413cc6..c19036e5 100644 --- a/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-conversion.yaml +++ b/software/applications/osdu-reference/crs-conversion.yaml @@ -64,7 +64,7 @@ spec: - "/api/crs/converter/api-docs*" - "/api/crs/converter/webjars/*" pvc: - - name: osdu-reference-osdu-developer-base-reference + - name: share-crs-conversion existing: true volume: shared-data mount: diff --git a/software/applications/osdu-reference/storage-volumes.yaml b/software/applications/osdu-reference/storage-volumes.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..9a418207 --- /dev/null +++ b/software/applications/osdu-reference/storage-volumes.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +--- +apiVersion: helm.toolkit.fluxcd.io/v2beta1 +kind: HelmRelease +metadata: + name: storage-volumes + namespace: default + annotations: + clusterconfig.azure.com/use-managed-source: "true" +spec: + targetNamespace: osdu-reference + releaseName: storage-volumes + chart: + spec: + chart: ./charts/storage-volumes + sourceRef: + kind: GitRepository + name: flux-system + namespace: flux-system + interval: 5m0s + install: + remediation: + retries: 3 + valuesFrom: + - kind: ConfigMap + name: config-map-values + valuesKey: values.yaml + values: + volumes: + - volumeName: "share-unit" + containerName: "share-unit" + - volumeName: "share-crs" + containerName: "share-crs" + - volumeName: "share-crs-conversion" + containerName: "share-crs-conversion" \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/software/applications/osdu-reference/unit.yaml b/software/applications/osdu-reference/unit.yaml index 00785fce..983a0d23 100644 --- a/software/applications/osdu-reference/unit.yaml +++ b/software/applications/osdu-reference/unit.yaml @@ -64,13 +64,12 @@ spec: - "/api/unit/api-docs*" - "/api/unit/webjars/*" pvc: - - name: osdu-reference-osdu-developer-base-reference + - name: share-unit existing: true volume: shared-data mount: - name: shared-data path: /mnt/unit_catalogs - subPath: unit env: - name: KEYVAULT_URI secret: diff --git a/software/components/airflow/release.yaml b/software/components/airflow/release.yaml index 28d419c4..15f78b80 100644 --- a/software/components/airflow/release.yaml +++ b/software/components/airflow/release.yaml @@ -32,17 +32,20 @@ spec: name: airflow-community namespace: flux-system values: - + # triggerer: + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" + serviceAccount: + create: false + name: workload-identity-sa airflow: + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" image: repository: apache/airflow tag: 2.10.1-python3.12 executor: KubernetesExecutor - # serviceAccount: - # create: false - # name: workload-identity-sa - # annotations: - # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" + securityContext: fsGroup: 1000 runAsUser: 1000 @@ -59,6 +62,9 @@ spec: email: admin@example.com firstName: admin lastName: admin + # dbMigrations: + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" # extraVolumeMounts: # ## spec: https://kubernetes.io/docs/reference/generated/kubernetes-api/v1.29/#volumemount-v1-core # - name: logs-volume @@ -84,8 +90,8 @@ spec: - "osdu-ingestion>=0.27,<1.0.0" kubernetesPodTemplate: serviceAccountName: workload-identity-sa - annotations: - azure.workload.identity/use: "true" + # annotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" extraPipPackages: # - "apache-airflow-providers-microsoft-azure" - "--extra-index-url=https://community.opengroup.org/api/v4/projects/148/packages/pypi/simple" @@ -242,13 +248,19 @@ spec: scheduler: logCleanup: enabled: false + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" workers: enabled: false logCleanup: enabled: false + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" web: enabled: true path: "/airflow" + # podAnnotations: + # azure.workload.identity/use: "true" ingress: enabled: false diff --git a/software/components/airflow/storage-volumes.yaml b/software/components/airflow/storage-volumes.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..d4a8a6b2 --- /dev/null +++ b/software/components/airflow/storage-volumes.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,32 @@ +--- +apiVersion: helm.toolkit.fluxcd.io/v2beta1 +kind: HelmRelease +metadata: + name: storage-volumes + namespace: default + annotations: + clusterconfig.azure.com/use-managed-source: "true" +spec: + targetNamespace: airflow + releaseName: storage-volumes + chart: + spec: + chart: ./charts/storage-volumes + sourceRef: + kind: GitRepository + name: flux-system + namespace: flux-system + interval: 5m0s + install: + remediation: + retries: 3 + valuesFrom: + - kind: ConfigMap + name: config-map-values + valuesKey: values.yaml + values: + volumes: + - volumeName: "airflow-logs" + containerName: "airflow-logs" + - volumeName: "airflow-dags" + containerName: "airflow-dags" \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/software/components/airflow/storage.yaml b/software/components/airflow/storage.yaml deleted file mode 100644 index a7976f26..00000000 --- a/software/components/airflow/storage.yaml +++ /dev/null @@ -1,48 +0,0 @@ ---- -apiVersion: storage.k8s.io/v1 -kind: StorageClass -metadata: - name: airflow-storage -provisioner: file.csi.azure.com -parameters: - skuName: Standard_LRS -allowVolumeExpansion: true -mountOptions: - - dir_mode=0777 - - file_mode=0777 - - uid=1000 - - gid=1000 - - mfsymlinks - - nobrl -reclaimPolicy: Delete -volumeBindingMode: Immediate ---- -apiVersion: v1 -kind: PersistentVolumeClaim -metadata: - name: airflow-logs-pvc - namespace: airflow - annotations: - csi.storage.k8s.io/share-name: "airflow-logs" -spec: - accessModes: - - ReadWriteMany - storageClassName: airflow-storage - resources: - requests: - storage: 5Gi ---- -apiVersion: v1 -kind: PersistentVolumeClaim -metadata: - name: airflow-dags-pvc - namespace: airflow - annotations: - csi.storage.k8s.io/share-name: "airflow-dags" -spec: - accessModes: - - ReadWriteMany - storageClassName: airflow-storage - resources: - requests: - storage: 5Gi \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/software/components/global/gateway-api-crd.yaml b/software/components/global/gateway-api-crd.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..6cff5364 --- /dev/null +++ b/software/components/global/gateway-api-crd.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,10345 @@ +# Copyright 2024 The Kubernetes Authors. +# +# Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); +# you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. +# You may obtain a copy of the License at +# +# http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0 +# +# Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software +# distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS, +# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. +# See the License for the specific language governing permissions and +# limitations under the License. + +# +# Gateway API Standard channel install +# +--- +# +# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gatewayclasses.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.1 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + creationTimestamp: null + name: gatewayclasses.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: GatewayClass + listKind: GatewayClassList + plural: gatewayclasses + shortNames: + - gc + singular: gatewayclass + scope: Cluster + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName + name: Controller + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status + name: Accepted + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + - jsonPath: .spec.description + name: Description + priority: 1 + type: string + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating + Gateway resources. + + It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This + means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it + was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not + propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to + limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters. + If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing + Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation. + + Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD + add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the + associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a + Gateway is not deleted while in use. + + GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass. + properties: + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of + this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + This field is not mutable and cannot be empty. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Value is immutable + rule: self == oldSelf + description: + description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details. + maxLength: 64 + type: string + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap, + or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be + cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped. + + If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when + the data within that resource is malformed, the GatewayClass SHOULD be + rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an + "InvalidParameters" reason. + + A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. + This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and + MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Status defines the current state of GatewayClass. + + Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which + specify their controller name. + properties: + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Conditions is the current status from the controller for + this GatewayClass. + + Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values + of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName + name: Controller + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status + name: Accepted + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + - jsonPath: .spec.description + name: Description + priority: 1 + type: string + name: v1beta1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating + Gateway resources. + + It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This + means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it + was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not + propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to + limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters. + If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing + Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation. + + Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD + add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the + associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a + Gateway is not deleted while in use. + + GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass. + properties: + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of + this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + This field is not mutable and cannot be empty. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Value is immutable + rule: self == oldSelf + description: + description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details. + maxLength: 64 + type: string + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap, + or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be + cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped. + + If the referent cannot be found, refers to an unsupported kind, or when + the data within that resource is malformed, the GatewayClass SHOULD be + rejected with the "Accepted" status condition set to "False" and an + "InvalidParameters" reason. + + A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. + This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and + MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Status defines the current state of GatewayClass. + + Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which + specify their controller name. + properties: + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + description: |- + Conditions is the current status from the controller for + this GatewayClass. + + Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values + of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: false + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gateways.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.1 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + creationTimestamp: null + name: gateways.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: Gateway + listKind: GatewayList + plural: gateways + shortNames: + - gtw + singular: gateway + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName + name: Class + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value + name: Address + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status + name: Programmed + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure + by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |+ + Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can + depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the + requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST + indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the + "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. + This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or + other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will + be sent to. + + If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the + Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate + set of Addresses. + + The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that + it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in + GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + Support: Extended + + items: + description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound + to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend + on the type and support by the controller. + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - value + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: IPAddress values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + - message: Hostname values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + gatewayClassName: + description: |- + GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a + GatewayClass resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + infrastructure: + description: |- + Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. + + Support: Extended + properties: + annotations: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional + DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of + up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a + DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + labels: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation + of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes + label validation rules: + * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), + * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), + * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + + Valid values include: + + * MyValue + * my.name + * 123-my-value + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 0 + pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ + type: string + description: |- + Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + + If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels + change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain + prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS + subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + + The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + type: object + listeners: + description: |- + Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define + logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses. + At least one Listener MUST be specified. + + Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway) + MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to + exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than + "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration + from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_ + apply in that case). + + Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique + combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname. + + Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered + Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their + targeted conformance profile: + + HTTP Profile + + 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP + 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided + + TLS Profile + + 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough + + "Distinct" Listeners have the following property: + + The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct + Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for + example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation + can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other + Listener fields. + + For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct: + + 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP" + Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. + 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or + "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. + 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener + with the same Protocol has the same Port value. + + Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect + whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant + for HTTP or HTTPS protocols. + + When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol + Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the + Listener to be distinct. + + When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request + hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname + values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes. + + Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard + matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) + matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over + `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`. + + Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific + wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries. + For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`. + The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the + hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence. + + The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to + the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both + `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`. + + If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those + Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" + condition in the Listener Status to "True". + + Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted + Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains + no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may + accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting + Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner. + This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting + Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at + least one Listener must be present. + + The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the + Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or + not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly + indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are + Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD + indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted. + + A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if: + + 1. They are distinct. + 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses + requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned + addresses. + + Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across + implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation + may not be compatible for another. + + For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners + on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port + would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct. + + Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if + Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a + request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached + to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). + This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do + not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this. + + Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of + Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts + network connections. + properties: + allowedRoutes: + default: + namespaces: + from: Same + description: |- + AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a + Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be + present. + + Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule + may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria: + + * The most specific match as defined by the Route type. + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with + a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over + a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04". + * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in + alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For + example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz. + + All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be + implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean + the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid, + support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For + example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest + of the rules within that Route should still be supported. + + Support: Core + properties: + kinds: + description: |- + Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind + to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes + selected are determined using the Listener protocol. + + A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible + with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field. + If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it + MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the + "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. + + Support: Core + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind + of a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + namespaces: + default: + from: Same + description: |- + Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this + Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default. + + Support: Core + properties: + from: + default: Same + description: |- + From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway. + * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by + this Gateway. + * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway. + + Support: Core + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + + Support: Core + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label + selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the + selector applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that + define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This + field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based + matching. + + Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of + the following protocols: + + * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. + * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. + * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP + protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not + ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname, + it MUST clearly document that. + + For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the + `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, + there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be + accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames + documentation. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a + Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the + same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules. + + Support: Core + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + protocol: + description: |- + Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 255 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$ + type: string + tls: + description: |- + TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if + the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field + if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP". + + The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is + defined based on the Hostname field for this listener. + + The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all + available certificates for any TLS handshake. + + Support: Core + properties: + certificateRefs: + description: |- + CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that + contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to + establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the + associated listener. + + A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + + This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set + to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise. + + CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types) + items: + description: |- + SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace, + defaulting to Secret. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + mode: + default: Terminate + description: |- + Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client. + There are two possible modes: + + - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the + Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates + to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs + field. + - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This + implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for + the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field + is ignored in this mode. + + Support: Core + enum: + - Terminate + - Passthrough + type: string + options: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS + configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the + minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. + + A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid + any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use + domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. + Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. + + Support: Implementation-specific + maxProperties: 16 + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when + mode is Terminate + rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs) + > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true' + required: + - name + - port + - protocol + type: object + maxItems: 64 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP', + 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? + !has(l.tls) : true)' + - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS + rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode + == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)' + - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname) + || l.hostname == '''') : true)' + - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway + rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name)) + - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique + for each listener + rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol + == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname + == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))' + required: + - gatewayClassName + - listeners + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: Status defines the current state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |+ + Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the + Gateway. + + This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some + conditions: + + * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned + * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned + * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use) + + items: + description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that + is bound to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend + on the type and support by the controller. + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - value + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: |- + Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway. + + Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions + using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason` + constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common + vocabulary to describe Gateway state. + + Known condition types are: + + * "Accepted" + * "Programmed" + * "Ready" + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + listeners: + description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port + defined in the Spec. + items: + description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener. + properties: + attachedRoutes: + description: |- + AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been + successfully attached to this Listener. + + Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the + combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener + and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to + a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field + AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway + resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on + attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various + Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact + successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set + for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully + attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions. + + Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and + measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener. + format: int32 + type: integer + conditions: + description: Conditions describe the current condition of this + listener. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + name: + description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status + corresponds to. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + supportedKinds: + description: |- + SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this + listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for + that Listener configuration. + + If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT + appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" + condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid + and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST + reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified. + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of + a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + required: + - attachedRoutes + - conditions + - name + - supportedKinds + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName + name: Class + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value + name: Address + type: string + - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status + name: Programmed + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1beta1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure + by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |+ + Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can + depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the + requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST + indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the + "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use. + This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or + other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will + be sent to. + + If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the + Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate + set of Addresses. + + The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that + it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in + GatewayStatus.Addresses. + + Support: Extended + + items: + description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound + to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend + on the type and support by the controller. + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - value + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: IPAddress values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + - message: Hostname values must be unique + rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2, + a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )' + gatewayClassName: + description: |- + GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a + GatewayClass resource. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + infrastructure: + description: |- + Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance. + + Support: Extended + properties: + annotations: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Annotation keys must be in the form of an optional + DNS subdomain prefix followed by a required name segment of + up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the annotation key's prefix must be a + DNS subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + labels: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + LabelValue is the value of a label in the Gateway API. This is used for validation + of maps such as Gateway infrastructure labels. This matches the Kubernetes + label validation rules: + * must be 63 characters or less (can be empty), + * unless empty, must begin and end with an alphanumeric character ([a-z0-9A-Z]), + * could contain dashes (-), underscores (_), dots (.), and alphanumerics between. + + Valid values include: + + * MyValue + * my.name + * 123-my-value + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 0 + pattern: ^(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])?$ + type: string + description: |- + Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway. + + For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources. + For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts. + + An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit. + + If an implementation maps these labels to Pods, or any other resource that would need to be recreated when labels + change, it SHOULD clearly warn about this behavior in documentation. + + Support: Extended + maxProperties: 8 + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Label keys must be in the form of an optional DNS subdomain + prefix followed by a required name segment of up to 63 characters. + rule: self.all(key, key.matches(r"""^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]{0,61})?[A-Za-z0-9]$""")) + - message: If specified, the label key's prefix must be a DNS + subdomain not longer than 253 characters in total. + rule: self.all(key, key.split("/")[0].size() < 253) + parametersRef: + description: |- + ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration + parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the + controller does not require any additional configuration. + + This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis + + The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified, + the merging behavior is implementation specific. + It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: Group is the group of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + type: object + listeners: + description: |- + Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define + logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses. + At least one Listener MUST be specified. + + Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway) + MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to + exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than + "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration + from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_ + apply in that case). + + Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique + combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname. + + Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered + Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their + targeted conformance profile: + + HTTP Profile + + 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP + 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided + + TLS Profile + + 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough + + "Distinct" Listeners have the following property: + + The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct + Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for + example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation + can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other + Listener fields. + + For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct: + + 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP" + Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. + 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or + "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values. + 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener + with the same Protocol has the same Port value. + + Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect + whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant + for HTTP or HTTPS protocols. + + When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol + Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the + Listener to be distinct. + + When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request + hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname + values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes. + + Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard + matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value) + matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over + `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`. + + Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific + wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries. + For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`. + The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the + hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence. + + The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to + the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both + `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`. + + If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those + Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted" + condition in the Listener Status to "True". + + Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted + Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains + no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may + accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting + Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner. + This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting + Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at + least one Listener must be present. + + The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the + Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or + not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly + indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are + Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD + indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted. + + A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if: + + 1. They are distinct. + 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses + requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned + addresses. + + Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across + implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation + may not be compatible for another. + + For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners + on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port + would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct. + + Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if + Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a + request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached + to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener). + This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do + not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this. + + Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of + Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts + network connections. + properties: + allowedRoutes: + default: + namespaces: + from: Same + description: |- + AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a + Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be + present. + + Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule + may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria: + + * The most specific match as defined by the Route type. + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with + a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over + a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04". + * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in + alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For + example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz. + + All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be + implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean + the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid, + support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For + example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest + of the rules within that Route should still be supported. + + Support: Core + properties: + kinds: + description: |- + Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind + to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes + selected are determined using the Listener protocol. + + A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible + with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field. + If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it + MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the + "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. + + Support: Core + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind + of a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + namespaces: + default: + from: Same + description: |- + Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this + Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default. + + Support: Core + properties: + from: + default: Same + description: |- + From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible + values are: + + * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway. + * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by + this Gateway. + * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway. + + Support: Core + enum: + - All + - Selector + - Same + type: string + selector: + description: |- + Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case, + only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this + Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From". + + Support: Core + properties: + matchExpressions: + description: matchExpressions is a list of label + selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed. + items: + description: |- + A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that + relates the key and values. + properties: + key: + description: key is the label key that the + selector applies to. + type: string + operator: + description: |- + operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values. + Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist. + type: string + values: + description: |- + values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn, + the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist, + the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic + merge patch. + items: + type: string + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + required: + - key + - operator + type: object + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic + matchLabels: + additionalProperties: + type: string + description: |- + matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels + map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the + operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed. + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic + type: object + type: object + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that + define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This + field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based + matching. + + Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of + the following protocols: + + * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI. + * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request. + * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP + protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not + ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname, + it MUST clearly document that. + + For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the + `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames, + there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be + accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames + documentation. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a + Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the + same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules. + + Support: Core + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + protocol: + description: |- + Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 255 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$ + type: string + tls: + description: |- + TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if + the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field + if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP". + + The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is + defined based on the Hostname field for this listener. + + The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all + available certificates for any TLS handshake. + + Support: Core + properties: + certificateRefs: + description: |- + CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that + contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to + establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the + associated listener. + + A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support. + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to + a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific. + + References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there + is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate + to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the + "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the + "RefNotPermitted" reason. + + This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set + to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise. + + CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e. + Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources. + + Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls + + Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types) + items: + description: |- + SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace, + defaulting to Secret. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + + References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must + be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set + on the containing object. + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Secret + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "Secret". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + mode: + default: Terminate + description: |- + Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client. + There are two possible modes: + + - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the + Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates + to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs + field. + - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This + implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for + the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field + is ignored in this mode. + + Support: Core + enum: + - Terminate + - Passthrough + type: string + options: + additionalProperties: + description: |- + AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used + for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes + annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based + on the entire size of the annotations struct. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 0 + type: string + description: |- + Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS + configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the + minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites. + + A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid + any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use + domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`. + Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API. + + Support: Implementation-specific + maxProperties: 16 + type: object + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when + mode is Terminate + rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs) + > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true' + required: + - name + - port + - protocol + type: object + maxItems: 64 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP', + 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? + !has(l.tls) : true)' + - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS + rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode + == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)' + - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP'] + rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname) + || l.hostname == '''') : true)' + - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway + rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name)) + - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique + for each listener + rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol + == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname + == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))' + required: + - gatewayClassName + - listeners + type: object + status: + default: + conditions: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: Status defines the current state of Gateway. + properties: + addresses: + description: |+ + Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the + Gateway. + + This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some + conditions: + + * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned + * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned + * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use) + + items: + description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that + is bound to a Gateway. + oneOf: + - properties: + type: + enum: + - IPAddress + value: + anyOf: + - format: ipv4 + - format: ipv6 + - properties: + type: + not: + enum: + - IPAddress + properties: + type: + default: IPAddress + description: Type of the address. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + value: + description: |- + Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend + on the type and support by the controller. + + Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - value + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$) + rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""): + true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + conditions: + default: + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Accepted + - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z" + message: Waiting for controller + reason: Pending + status: Unknown + type: Programmed + description: |- + Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway. + + Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions + using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason` + constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common + vocabulary to describe Gateway state. + + Known condition types are: + + * "Accepted" + * "Programmed" + * "Ready" + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of the current + state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + listeners: + description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port + defined in the Spec. + items: + description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener. + properties: + attachedRoutes: + description: |- + AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been + successfully attached to this Listener. + + Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the + combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener + and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to + a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field + AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway + resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on + attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various + Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact + successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set + for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully + attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions. + + Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and + measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener. + format: int32 + type: integer + conditions: + description: Conditions describe the current condition of this + listener. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + name: + description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status + corresponds to. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + supportedKinds: + description: |- + SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this + listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for + that Listener configuration. + + If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT + appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" + condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid + and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST + reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified. + items: + description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of + a Route resource. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: Group is the group of the Route. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is the kind of the Route. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + required: + - attachedRoutes + - conditions + - name + - supportedKinds + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: false + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_grpcroutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.1 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + creationTimestamp: null + name: grpcroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: GRPCRoute + listKind: GRPCRouteList + plural: grpcroutes + singular: grpcroute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames + name: Hostnames + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability + to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header. + Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify + where matching requests will be routed. + + GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the + following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation + supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an + implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement + unless explicitly indicated. + + Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST + accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via + ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the + "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of + "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections + with an upgrade from HTTP/1. + + Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST + support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c, + https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial + upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge + (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation + does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False" + for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol". + Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from + HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute. + properties: + hostnames: + description: |- + Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC + Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label MUST appear by itself as the first label. + + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there + MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be + attached to the Listener. For example: + + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at + least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least + one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, + `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other + hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any + GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the + GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match. + + If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by + the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition + with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a + Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other + type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is + non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two + routes, determined by the following criteria, in order: + + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". + + The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of + 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating + dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a + domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). + + Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case + alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric + character. No other punctuation is allowed. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + parentRefs: + description: |+ + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: + + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. + + Some examples: + + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. + + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. + + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + + + + + + + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''')) : true))' + - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or + more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)))) + rules: + description: |+ + Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions. + + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on + conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to + an API object (backendRefs). + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. + + Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and + how many are invalid. + + If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters + specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST + receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + + See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single + GRPCBackendRef invalid. + + When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for + requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If + multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of + requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend + MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + + For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is + invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status. + Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined. + + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + + Support for weight: Core + items: + description: |- + GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + + + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + + + properties: + filters: + description: |- + Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the + request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + + Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the + Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.) + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + Support: Implementation-specific + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind + == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |+ + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + enum: + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - ExtensionRef + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for + RequestMirror filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == + ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for + ExtensionRef filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 + description: |- + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. + + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. + + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + filters: + description: |- + Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match + this rule. + + The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified. + This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage. + + Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: + + - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support + GRPCRoute. + - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. + - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across + implementations. + + Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly + indicated in the filter. + + If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly + document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported + filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status + `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify + this configuration error. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + Support: Implementation-specific + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |+ + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + enum: + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - ExtensionRef + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type == + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + matches: + description: |- + Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming + gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched + if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. + + For example, take the following matches configuration: + + ``` + matches: + - method: + service: foo.bar + headers: + values: + version: 2 + - method: + service: foo.bar.v2 + ``` + + For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy + EITHER of the two conditions: + + - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2` + - service of foo.bar.v2 + + See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple + match conditions to be ANDed together. + + If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request. + + Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes + MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on + ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes. + Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of: + + * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. + * Characters in a matching hostname. + * Characters in a matching service. + * Characters in a matching method. + * Header matches. + + If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: + + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". + + If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence, + matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting + the above criteria. + items: + description: |- + GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given + action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will + evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied. + + For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service + is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header: + + ``` + matches: + - method: + type: Exact + service: "foo" + headers: + - name: "version" + value "v1" + + ``` + properties: + headers: + description: |- + Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are + ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers + to select the route. + items: + description: |- + GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request + headers. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched. + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: Type specifies how to match against + the value of the header. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + method: + description: |- + Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is + not specified, all services and methods will match. + properties: + method: + description: |- + Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will + match all services. + + At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + service: + description: |- + Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will + match any service. + + At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method. + Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be + specified + rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method) + : true' + - message: service must only contain valid characters + (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$) + rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && + has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""): + true' + - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching + ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$) + rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') && + has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""): + true' + type: object + maxItems: 8 + type: array + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the + total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less + than 128 + rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? (has(self[0].matches) ? self[0].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 1 ? (has(self[1].matches) ? self[1].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? (has(self[2].matches) ? self[2].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? (has(self[3].matches) ? self[3].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 4 ? (has(self[4].matches) ? self[4].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? (has(self[5].matches) ? self[5].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? (has(self[6].matches) ? self[6].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 7 ? (has(self[7].matches) ? self[7].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? (has(self[8].matches) ? self[8].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? (has(self[9].matches) ? self[9].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 10 ? (has(self[10].matches) ? self[10].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? (has(self[11].matches) ? self[11].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? (has(self[12].matches) ? self[12].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 13 ? (has(self[13].matches) ? self[13].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? (has(self[14].matches) ? self[14].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? (has(self[15].matches) ? self[15].matches.size() + : 0) : 0) <= 128' + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. + + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. + + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. + + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_httproutes.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.1 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + creationTimestamp: null + name: httproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: HTTPRoute + listKind: HTTPRouteList + plural: httproutes + singular: httproute + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames + name: Hostnames + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability + to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be + used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching + requests should be routed. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute. + properties: + hostnames: + description: |- + Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host + header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations + MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while + performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification + configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend. + + Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a + hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there + must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be + attached to the Listener. For example: + + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at + least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least + one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, + `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would + all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would + not match. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any + HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the + HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match. + + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The + implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of + `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g. + overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must + be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of: + + * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. + * Characters in a matching hostname. + + If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for + HTTPRouteMatches takes over. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating + dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a + domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). + + Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case + alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric + character. No other punctuation is allowed. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + parentRefs: + description: |+ + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: + + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. + + Some examples: + + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. + + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. + + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + + + + + + + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''')) : true))' + - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or + more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)))) + rules: + default: + - matches: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |+ + Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. + + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on + conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to + an API object (backendRefs). + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. + + Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and + how many are invalid. + + If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters + specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST + receive a 500 status code. + + See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single + HTTPBackendRef invalid. + + When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for + requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If + multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of + requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend + MUST receive a 500 status code. + + For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is + invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may + choose how that 50 percent is determined. + + When a HTTPBackendRef refers to a Service that has no ready endpoints, + implementations SHOULD return a 503 for requests to that backend instead. + If an implementation chooses to do this, all of the above rules for 500 responses + MUST also apply for responses that return a 503. + + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + + Support for weight: Core + items: + description: |- + HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + + + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + + + properties: + filters: + description: |- + Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the + request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + + Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the + Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind + == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations must support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite + - ExtensionRef + type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for + RequestMirror filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == + ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified + for RequestRedirect filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for + ExtensionRef filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() + <= 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() + <= 1 + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 + description: |- + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. + + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. + + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + filters: + description: |- + Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match + this rule. + + Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order + they are specified. + + Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting + any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations + choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document + that behavior. + + To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD + consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules + in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only + a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the + "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route. + + Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: + + - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations. + - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. + - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across + implementations. + + Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly + indicated in the filter. + + All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the + URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an + implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly + document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported + filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status + `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify + this configuration error. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations must support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite + - ExtensionRef + type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type == + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') && + self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <= + 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1 + matches: + default: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |- + Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming + HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched + if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. + + For example, take the following matches configuration: + + ``` + matches: + - path: + value: "/foo" + headers: + - name: "version" + value: "v2" + - path: + value: "/v2/foo" + ``` + + For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy + EITHER of the two conditions: + + - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2` + - path prefix of `/v2/foo` + + See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple + match conditions that should be ANDed together. + + If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix + path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every + HTTP request. + + Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes + MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on + ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be + given to the match having: + + * "Exact" path match. + * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters. + * Method match. + * Largest number of header matches. + * Largest number of query param matches. + + Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific. + + If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: + + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". + + If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted + to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above + criteria. + + When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the + parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned. + items: + description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to + match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types + are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true + only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\nFor example, the + match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts + with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\tpath:\n\t + \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t + \ value \"v1\"\n\n```" + properties: + headers: + description: |- + Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are + ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers + to select the route. + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request + headers. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + + When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is + implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented. + Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC: + https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding + processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie". + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the header. + + Support: Core (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects + of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to + determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to + be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + method: + description: |- + Method specifies HTTP method matcher. + When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the + specified method. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + type: string + path: + default: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |- + Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not + specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided. + properties: + type: + default: PathPrefix + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the path Value. + + Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + enum: + - Exact + - PathPrefix + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + default: / + description: Value of the HTTP path to match against. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: value must be an absolute path and start with + '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'') + : true' + - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix', + 'RegularExpression'] + rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type + == 'RegularExpression' + - message: must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$) + for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""") + : true' + queryParams: + description: |- + QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match + values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the + specified query parameters to select the route. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP + query parameters. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an + exact string match. (See + https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored. + + If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is + purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different + capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should + match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it, + as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of + the Gateway API. + + Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard + themselves against potential differences in the implementations. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + + Support: Extended (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other + dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's + documentation to determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP query param + to be matched. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + timeouts: + description: |- + Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request. + + Support: Extended + properties: + backendRequest: + description: |- + BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway + to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being + sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend. + + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. + + An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout, + may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend, + for example, if automatic retries are supported. + + The value of BackendRequest must be a Gateway API Duration string as defined by + GEP-2257. When this field is unspecified, its behavior is implementation-specific; + when specified, the value of BackendRequest must be no more than the value of the + Request timeout (since the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout). + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + request: + description: |- + Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request. + If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway + MUST return a timeout error. + + For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an + `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds + to complete. + + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. + + This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction + as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire + request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is + initiated by the client. + + The value of Request is a Gateway API Duration string as defined by GEP-2257. When this + field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request + timeout + rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) && + duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest) + > duration(self.request))' + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with + backendRefs + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ? + (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))): + true' + - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || + self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter + with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must + be specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) + || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with + path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be + specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the + total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less + than 128 + rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? self[0].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 1 ? self[1].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? self[2].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? self[3].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 4 ? self[4].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? self[5].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? self[6].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 7 ? self[7].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? self[8].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? self[9].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 10 ? self[10].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? self[11].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? self[12].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 13 ? self[13].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? self[14].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? self[15].matches.size() : 0) <= 128' + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. + + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. + + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. + + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: + status: {} + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames + name: Hostnames + type: string + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1beta1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability + to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be + used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching + requests should be routed. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute. + properties: + hostnames: + description: |- + Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host + header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations + MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while + performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification + configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend. + + Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a + hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there + must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be + attached to the Listener. For example: + + * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at + least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`. + * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes + that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least + one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example, + `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would + all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would + not match. + + Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted + as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match + both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`. + + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any + HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be + ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the + HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`, + `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match. + + If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none + match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The + implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of + `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus. + + In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g. + overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must + be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of: + + * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname. + * Characters in a matching hostname. + + If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for + HTTPRouteMatches takes over. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches + the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions: + + 1. IPs are not allowed. + 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard + label must appear by itself as the first label. + + Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating + dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a + domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`). + + Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case + alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric + character. No other punctuation is allowed. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + parentRefs: + description: |+ + ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants + to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to + allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means + the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and + namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same + namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support + and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is + not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to + create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the + Route. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that: + + * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef + entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the + multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must + be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route. + * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used, + each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of + optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a + combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination. + + Some examples: + + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the + same object must also set `sectionName`. + * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same + object must also set `port`. + * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs + referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`. + + It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may + be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may + choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the + case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be + merged. + + Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific + rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example, + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference. + + + + + + + items: + description: |- + ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered + a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources + with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent + resources. + + The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must + be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes + 2 or more references to the same parent + rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '''')) : true))' + - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or + more references to the same parent + rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind + == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__) + || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__ + == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) && + p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName) + || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName + == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName + == p2.sectionName)))) + rules: + default: + - matches: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |+ + Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions. + + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on + conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to + an API object (backendRefs). + properties: + backendRefs: + description: |- + BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be + sent. + + Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and + how many are invalid. + + If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters + specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST + receive a 500 status code. + + See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single + HTTPBackendRef invalid. + + When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for + requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If + multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of + requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend + MUST receive a 500 status code. + + For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is + invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may + choose how that 50 percent is determined. + + When a HTTPBackendRef refers to a Service that has no ready endpoints, + implementations SHOULD return a 503 for requests to that backend instead. + If an implementation chooses to do this, all of the above rules for 500 responses + MUST also apply for responses that return a 503. + + Support: Core for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + + Support for weight: Core + items: + description: |- + HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a + ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + + + When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD + honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port. + + Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes + Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726. + + If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the + backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the + protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service. + + If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified + protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the + "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason. + + + properties: + filters: + description: |- + Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the + request is being forwarded to the backend defined here. + + Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the + Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.) + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For + example "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind + == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP + Header name and value as defined by RFC + 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP + Header to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations must support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite + - ExtensionRef + type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? + has(self.replaceFullPath) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when + replaceFullPath is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type + == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified + when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + when replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil + if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for + RequestMirror filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == + ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified + for RequestRedirect filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == + ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for + ExtensionRef filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') + && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() + <= 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() + <= 1 + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + weight: + default: 1 + description: |- + Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced + backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this + BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from + the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an + implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of + weights does not need to equal 100. + + If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100% + of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no + traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight + defaults to 1. + + Support for this field varies based on the context where used. + format: int32 + maximum: 1000000 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + filters: + description: |- + Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match + this rule. + + Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order + they are specified. + + Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting + any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations + choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document + that behavior. + + To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD + consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules + in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only + a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the + "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route. + + Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter: + + - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations. + - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters. + - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across + implementations. + + Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly + indicated in the filter. + + All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the + URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an + implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly + document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported + filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status + `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify + this configuration error. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the + request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension + point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some + examples include request or response modification, implementing + authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API + guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter. + properties: + extensionRef: + description: |- + ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the + "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group + "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and + extended filters. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. + + Support: Implementation-specific + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example + "HTTPRoute" or "Service". + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - name + type: object + requestHeaderModifier: + description: |- + RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request + headers. + + Support: Core + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + requestMirror: + description: |+ + RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests. + Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from + that destination are ignored. + + This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that + not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple + backends. + + Support: Extended + + properties: + backendRef: + description: |- + BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent. + + Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint + within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present + within this BackendRef. + + If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be + dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs" + condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure + this backend in the underlying implementation. + + If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object + that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the + "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`, + with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the + underlying implementation. + + In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition + should be used to provide more detail about the problem. + + Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service + + Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource + properties: + group: + default: "" + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io". + When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred. + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Service + description: |- + Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example + "Service". + + Defaults to "Service" when not specified. + + ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live + outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in + terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see + CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT + support ExternalName Services. + + Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName) + + Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName) + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: Name is the name of the referent. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local + namespace is inferred. + + Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, + a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that + namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant + documentation for details. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource. + Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this + case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port. + For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent + resource or this field. + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + required: + - name + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: Must have port for Service reference + rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'') + ? has(self.port) : true' + required: + - backendRef + type: object + requestRedirect: + description: |- + RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the + request with an HTTP redirection. + + Support: Core + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request. + The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When + empty, the request path is used as-is. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + port: + description: |- + Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location` + header in the response. + + If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the + following rules: + + * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known + port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80 + and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a + well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used. + * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway + Listener port. + + Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location' + header in the following cases: + + * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80. + * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via + the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + scheme: + description: |- + Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in + the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used. + + Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information, + refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - http + - https + type: string + statusCode: + default: 302 + description: |- + StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + + Support: Core + enum: + - 301 + - 302 + type: integer + type: object + responseHeaderModifier: + description: |- + ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response + headers. + + Support: Extended + properties: + add: + description: |- + Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request + before the action. It appends to any existing values associated + with the header name. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + add: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar,baz" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo,bar,baz + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + remove: + description: |- + Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The + value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header + names are case-insensitive (see + https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2). + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header1: foo + my-header2: bar + my-header3: baz + + Config: + remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"] + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header2: bar + items: + type: string + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-type: set + set: + description: |- + Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value) + before the action. + + Input: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: foo + + Config: + set: + - name: "my-header" + value: "bar" + + Output: + GET /foo HTTP/1.1 + my-header: bar + items: + description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header + name and value as defined by RFC 7230. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with + an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries + with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header + to be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + type: + description: |- + Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields, + types are classified into three conformance levels: + + - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All + implementations must support core filters. + + - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by + "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers + are encouraged to support extended filters. + + - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by + specific vendors. + In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple + implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core + conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters + is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to + "ExtensionRef" for custom filters. + + Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to + extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior. + + If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter + MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by + that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - RequestHeaderModifier + - ResponseHeaderModifier + - RequestMirror + - RequestRedirect + - URLRewrite + - ExtensionRef + type: string + urlRewrite: + description: |- + URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding. + + Support: Extended + properties: + hostname: + description: |- + Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during + forwarding. + + Support: Extended + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + path: + description: |- + Path defines a path rewrite. + + Support: Extended + properties: + replaceFullPath: + description: |- + ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path + of a request during a rewrite or redirect. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + replacePrefixMatch: + description: |- + ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix + match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request + to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch + of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar". + + Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This + matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels + in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is + ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all + match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not. + + ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch. + Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in + the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`. + + Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: + description: |- + Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be + added in a future release of the API. + + Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations + must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash. + + Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the + Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a + Reason of `UnsupportedValue`. + enum: + - ReplaceFullPath + - ReplacePrefixMatch + type: string + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath + is set + rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type == + ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true' + - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when + type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch' + rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) + : true' + - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when + replacePrefixMatch is set + rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true' + type: object + required: + - type + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified + for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type == + ''RequestHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the + filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier + rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type != + ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified + for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type + == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestMirror + rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type + is not RequestRedirect + rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type + is not URLRewrite + rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type + is not ExtensionRef + rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')' + - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef + filter.type + rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect + or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both + rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') && + self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))' + - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size() + <= 1 + - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <= + 1 + - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated + rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1 + matches: + default: + - path: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |- + Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming + HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched + if **any** one of the matches is satisfied. + + For example, take the following matches configuration: + + ``` + matches: + - path: + value: "/foo" + headers: + - name: "version" + value: "v2" + - path: + value: "/v2/foo" + ``` + + For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy + EITHER of the two conditions: + + - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2` + - path prefix of `/v2/foo` + + See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple + match conditions that should be ANDed together. + + If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix + path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every + HTTP request. + + Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes + MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on + ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be + given to the match having: + + * "Exact" path match. + * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters. + * Method match. + * Largest number of header matches. + * Largest number of query param matches. + + Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific. + + If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be + determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties: + + * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. + * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by + "{namespace}/{name}". + + If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted + to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above + criteria. + + When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the + parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned. + items: + description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to + match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types + are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true + only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\nFor example, the + match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts + with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\tpath:\n\t + \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t + \ value \"v1\"\n\n```" + properties: + headers: + description: |- + Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are + ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers + to select the route. + items: + description: |- + HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request + headers. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be + case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the + case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered + equivalent. + + When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is + implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented. + Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC: + https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding + processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie". + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the header. + + Support: Core (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects + of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to + determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to + be matched. + maxLength: 4096 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + method: + description: |- + Method specifies HTTP method matcher. + When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the + specified method. + + Support: Extended + enum: + - GET + - HEAD + - POST + - PUT + - DELETE + - CONNECT + - OPTIONS + - TRACE + - PATCH + type: string + path: + default: + type: PathPrefix + value: / + description: |- + Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not + specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided. + properties: + type: + default: PathPrefix + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the path Value. + + Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + enum: + - Exact + - PathPrefix + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + default: / + description: Value of the HTTP path to match against. + maxLength: 1024 + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: value must be an absolute path and start with + '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'') + : true' + - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'') + : true' + - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact', + 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'') + : true' + - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix', + 'RegularExpression'] + rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type + == 'RegularExpression' + - message: must only contain valid characters (matching + ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$) + for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix'] + rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""") + : true' + queryParams: + description: |- + QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match + values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the + specified query parameters to select the route. + + Support: Extended + items: + description: |- + HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP + query parameters. + properties: + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an + exact string match. (See + https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3). + + If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first + entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent + entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored. + + If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is + purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different + capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should + match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it, + as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of + the Gateway API. + + Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard + themselves against potential differences in the implementations. + maxLength: 256 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$ + type: string + type: + default: Exact + description: |- + Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter. + + Support: Extended (Exact) + + Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression) + + Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific + conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other + dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's + documentation to determine the supported dialect. + enum: + - Exact + - RegularExpression + type: string + value: + description: Value is the value of HTTP query param + to be matched. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - name + - value + type: object + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - name + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + type: object + maxItems: 64 + type: array + timeouts: + description: |- + Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request. + + Support: Extended + properties: + backendRequest: + description: |- + BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway + to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being + sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend. + + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. + + An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout, + may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend, + for example, if automatic retries are supported. + + The value of BackendRequest must be a Gateway API Duration string as defined by + GEP-2257. When this field is unspecified, its behavior is implementation-specific; + when specified, the value of BackendRequest must be no more than the value of the + Request timeout (since the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout). + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + request: + description: |- + Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request. + If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway + MUST return a timeout error. + + For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an + `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds + to complete. + + Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout + completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST + instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which + the timeout can be set. + + This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction + as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire + request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is + initiated by the client. + + The value of Request is a Gateway API Duration string as defined by GEP-2257. When this + field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific. + + Support: Extended + pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$ + type: string + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request + timeout + rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) && + duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest) + > duration(self.request))' + type: object + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with + backendRefs + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ? + (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))): + true' + - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || + self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch, + exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified + rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter + with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must + be specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect) + && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type + == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch))) + )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) + || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) + : true' + - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with + path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be + specified + rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b, + (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite) + && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' + && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches) + != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type + != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true' + maxItems: 16 + type: array + x-kubernetes-validations: + - message: While 16 rules and 64 matches per rule are allowed, the + total number of matches across all rules in a route must be less + than 128 + rule: '(self.size() > 0 ? self[0].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 1 ? self[1].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 2 ? self[2].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 3 ? self[3].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 4 ? self[4].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 5 ? self[5].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 6 ? self[6].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 7 ? self[7].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 8 ? self[8].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 9 ? self[9].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 10 ? self[10].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 11 ? self[11].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 12 ? self[12].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() + > 13 ? self[13].matches.size() : 0) + (self.size() > 14 ? self[14].matches.size() + : 0) + (self.size() > 15 ? self[15].matches.size() : 0) <= 128' + type: object + status: + description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute. + properties: + parents: + description: |- + Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are + associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to + each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that + manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller + first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the + route or gateway is modified. + + Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation + of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API + can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are + responsible for. + + A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list + means the route has not been attached to any Gateway. + items: + description: |- + RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an + associated Parent. + properties: + conditions: + description: |- + Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway. + Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own + status conditions and listener status. + + If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports + Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access, + then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the + Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the + Gateway, and why. + + A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's + rules is implemented by the Gateway. + + There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set + due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when: + + * The Route refers to a non-existent parent. + * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support. + * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to. + items: + description: Condition contains details for one aspect of + the current state of this API Resource. + properties: + lastTransitionTime: + description: |- + lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another. + This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable. + format: date-time + type: string + message: + description: |- + message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition. + This may be an empty string. + maxLength: 32768 + type: string + observedGeneration: + description: |- + observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon. + For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date + with respect to the current state of the instance. + format: int64 + minimum: 0 + type: integer + reason: + description: |- + reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition. + Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field, + and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API. + The value should be a CamelCase string. + This field may not be empty. + maxLength: 1024 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$ + type: string + status: + description: status of the condition, one of True, False, + Unknown. + enum: + - "True" + - "False" + - Unknown + type: string + type: + description: type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase. + maxLength: 316 + pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$ + type: string + required: + - lastTransitionTime + - message + - reason + - status + - type + type: object + maxItems: 8 + minItems: 1 + type: array + x-kubernetes-list-map-keys: + - type + x-kubernetes-list-type: map + controllerName: + description: |- + ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the + controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the + controllerName field on GatewayClass. + + Example: "example.net/gateway-controller". + + The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are + valid Kubernetes names + (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names). + + Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that + entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no + longer necessary. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$ + type: string + parentRef: + description: |- + ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this + RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of. + properties: + group: + default: gateway.networking.k8s.io + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred. + To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent), + Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string). + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + default: Gateway + description: |- + Kind is kind of the referent. + + There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support: + + * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile) + * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only) + + Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific. + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers + to the local namespace of the Route. + + Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace + boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly + allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example: + Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a + generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference. + + + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + port: + description: |- + Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted + differently based on the type of parent resource. + + When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners + listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and + select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the + networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port + as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port + and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener + must match both specified values. + + + + Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources. + Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly + document how/if Port is interpreted. + + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as + long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment + from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, + the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Extended + format: int32 + maximum: 65535 + minimum: 1 + type: integer + sectionName: + description: |- + SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the + following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following: + + * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName + are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match + both specified values. + + Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources. + If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is + interpreted. + + When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource. + For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at + least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway + listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind, + namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from + the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully + attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the + Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + required: + - name + type: object + required: + - controllerName + - parentRef + type: object + maxItems: 32 + type: array + required: + - parents + type: object + required: + - spec + type: object + served: true + storage: false + subresources: + status: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null +--- +# +# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_referencegrants.yaml +# +apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1 +kind: CustomResourceDefinition +metadata: + annotations: + api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/3328 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.2.1 + gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard + creationTimestamp: null + name: referencegrants.gateway.networking.k8s.io +spec: + group: gateway.networking.k8s.io + names: + categories: + - gateway-api + kind: ReferenceGrant + listKind: ReferenceGrantList + plural: referencegrants + shortNames: + - refgrant + singular: referencegrant + scope: Namespaced + versions: + - additionalPrinterColumns: + - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp + name: Age + type: date + name: v1beta1 + schema: + openAPIV3Schema: + description: |- + ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are + trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace + as the policy. + + Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship. + Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted + sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within. + + All cross-namespace references in Gateway API (with the exception of cross-namespace + Gateway-route attachment) require a ReferenceGrant. + + ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert + which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that + support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have + no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access + that the grant allowed. + properties: + apiVersion: + description: |- + APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object. + Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and + may reject unrecognized values. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents. + Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to. + Cannot be updated. + In CamelCase. + More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds + type: string + metadata: + type: object + spec: + description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant. + properties: + from: + description: |- + From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the + resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered + to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put + this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR. + + Support: Core + items: + description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and + kinds. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support + additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" + support level for this field. + + When used to permit a SecretObjectReference: + + * Gateway + + When used to permit a BackendObjectReference: + + * GRPCRoute + * HTTPRoute + * TCPRoute + * TLSRoute + * UDPRoute + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + namespace: + description: |- + Namespace is the namespace of the referent. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$ + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + - namespace + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + to: + description: |- + To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources + described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an + additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another + way, entries MUST be combined using OR. + + Support: Core + items: + description: |- + ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the + references. + properties: + group: + description: |- + Group is the group of the referent. + When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred. + + Support: Core + maxLength: 253 + pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$ + type: string + kind: + description: |- + Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support + additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core" + support level for this field: + + * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference + * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference + maxLength: 63 + minLength: 1 + pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$ + type: string + name: + description: |- + Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy + refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local + namespace. + maxLength: 253 + minLength: 1 + type: string + required: + - group + - kind + type: object + maxItems: 16 + minItems: 1 + type: array + required: + - from + - to + type: object + type: object + served: true + storage: true + subresources: {} +status: + acceptedNames: + kind: "" + plural: "" + conditions: null + storedVersions: null diff --git a/software/components/global/release.yaml b/software/components/global/release.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..b7280f22 --- /dev/null +++ b/software/components/global/release.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +apiVersion: helm.toolkit.fluxcd.io/v2beta1 +kind: HelmRelease +metadata: + name: blob-csi-driver + namespace: default +spec: + targetNamespace: kube-system + releaseName: blob-csi-driver + chart: + spec: + chart: blob-csi-driver + version: v1.26.1 + sourceRef: + kind: HelmRepository + name: blob-csi + namespace: flux-system + install: + remediation: + retries: 3 + interval: 10m0s + valuesFrom: + - kind: ConfigMap + name: config-map-values + valuesKey: values.yaml + values: + blobfuse2: + enabled: true + node: + tokenRequests: + - audience: api://AzureADTokenExchange + tolerations: + - key: kubernetes.azure.com/role + operator: Equal + value: agent + effect: NoSchedule + controller: + replicas: 1 + runOnControlPlane: false + serviceAccount: + create: true + controller: csi-blob-controller-sa + node: csi-blob-node-sa diff --git a/software/components/global/source.yaml b/software/components/global/source.yaml new file mode 100644 index 00000000..d78c1693 --- /dev/null +++ b/software/components/global/source.yaml @@ -0,0 +1,9 @@ +--- +apiVersion: source.toolkit.fluxcd.io/v1 +kind: HelmRepository +metadata: + name: blob-csi + namespace: flux-system +spec: + interval: 12h # Check for updates every 12 hours + url: https://raw.githubusercontent.com/kubernetes-sigs/blob-csi-driver/master/charts \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/src/applicationinsights-agent-3.7.1.jar b/src/applicationinsights-agent-3.7.1.jar new file mode 100644 index 00000000..b2f8e953 Binary files /dev/null and b/src/applicationinsights-agent-3.7.1.jar differ